blob: c5e6a1a4c8501caed773ad7b5b1e33d2df48c98c [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkb75190d2012-01-19 10:58:21 +01002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2012
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
5# See file CREDITS for list of people who contributed to this
6# project.
7#
8# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
10# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of
11# the License, or (at your option) any later version.
12#
13# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16# GNU General Public License for more details.
17#
18# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
20# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston,
21# MA 02111-1307 USA
22#
23
24Summary:
25========
26
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000027This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000028Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
29processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
30initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
31code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000032
33The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
35header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000036support booting of Linux images.
37
38Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
39configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
40implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
41add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
42code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
43load and run it dynamically.
44
45
46Status:
47=======
48
49In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000051"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
52
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000053In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010054who contributed the specific port. The MAINTAINERS file lists board
55maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000057
58Where to get help:
59==================
60
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000061In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
62U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050063<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
64on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
65Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
66http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000067
68
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010069Where to get source code:
70=========================
71
72The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
73git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
74http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
75
76The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020077any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010078available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
79directory.
80
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010081Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010082ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
83
84
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000085Where we come from:
86===================
87
88- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000090- clean up code
91- make it easier to add custom boards
92- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
93- extend functions, especially:
94 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
95 * S-Record download
96 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020097 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000098- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000099- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000100- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +0200101- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000102
103
104Names and Spelling:
105===================
106
107The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
108"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
109in source files etc.). Example:
110
111 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
112
113File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
114
115 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
116
117 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
118
119Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
120the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
121
122 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
123 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000124
125
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000126Versioning:
127===========
128
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200129Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
130were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
131into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
132names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
133Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
134releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000135
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200136Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000137 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200138 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
139 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000140
141
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000142Directory Hierarchy:
143====================
144
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500145/arch Architecture specific files
146 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
147 /cpu CPU specific files
148 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
149 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000150 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200151 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
152 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500153 /arm925t Files specific to ARM 925 CPUs
154 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
155 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
156 /ixp Files specific to Intel XScale IXP CPUs
157 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
158 /s3c44b0 Files specific to Samsung S3C44B0 CPUs
159 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
160 /lib Architecture specific library files
161 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
162 /cpu CPU specific files
163 /lib Architecture specific library files
164 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
165 /cpu CPU specific files
166 /lib Architecture specific library files
Graeme Russfea25722011-04-13 19:43:28 +1000167 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500168 /cpu CPU specific files
169 /lib Architecture specific library files
170 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
171 /cpu CPU specific files
172 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
173 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
174 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
175 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
176 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
177 /lib Architecture specific library files
178 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
179 /cpu CPU specific files
180 /lib Architecture specific library files
181 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
182 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200183 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Xiangfu Liu80421fc2011-10-12 12:24:06 +0800184 /xburst Files specific to Ingenic XBurst CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500185 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000186 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
187 /cpu CPU specific files
188 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
189 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500190 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
191 /cpu CPU specific files
192 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200193 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500194 /cpu CPU specific files
195 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
196 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
197 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
198 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
199 /mpc8220 Files specific to Freescale MPC8220 CPUs
200 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
201 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
202 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
203 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
204 /lib Architecture specific library files
205 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
206 /cpu CPU specific files
207 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
208 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
209 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
210 /lib Architecture specific library files
211 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
212 /cpu CPU specific files
213 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
214 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
215 /lib Architecture specific library files
216/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
217/board Board dependent files
218/common Misc architecture independent functions
219/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
220/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
221/drivers Commonly used device drivers
222/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
223/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
224/include Header Files
225/lib Files generic to all architectures
226 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
227 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
228 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
229/net Networking code
230/post Power On Self Test
231/rtc Real Time Clock drivers
232/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000233
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000234Software Configuration:
235=======================
236
237Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
238rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
239
240There are two classes of configuration variables:
241
242* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
243 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
244 "CONFIG_".
245
246* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
247 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
248 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200249 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000250
251Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
252identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
253do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
254links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
255as an example here.
256
257
258Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
259---------------------------------------------------
260
261For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
262configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_config".
263
264Example: For a TQM823L module type:
265
266 cd u-boot
267 make TQM823L_config
268
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200269For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000270e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_config". And also configure the cogent
271directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
272
273
274Configuration Options:
275----------------------
276
277Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
278such information is kept in a configuration file
279"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
280
281Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
282"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
283
284
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000285Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
286kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
287build a config tool - later.
288
289
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000290The following options need to be configured:
291
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500292- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000293
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500294- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200295
296- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100297 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000298
299- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
300 Define exactly one of
301 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
302--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
303 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
304 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
305
306- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
307 Define exactly one of
308 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
309
310- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
311 Define one or more of
312 CONFIG_CMA302
313
314- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
315 Define one or more of
316 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200317 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000318 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
319
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000320- Board flavour: (if CONFIG_MPC8260ADS is defined)
321 CONFIG_ADSTYPE
322 Possible values are:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200323 CONFIG_SYS_8260ADS - original MPC8260ADS
324 CONFIG_SYS_8266ADS - MPC8266ADS
325 CONFIG_SYS_PQ2FADS - PQ2FADS-ZU or PQ2FADS-VR
326 CONFIG_SYS_8272ADS - MPC8272ADS
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000327
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530328- Marvell Family Member
329 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
330 multiple fs option at one time
331 for marvell soc family
332
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000333- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000334 Define exactly one of
335 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000336
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200337- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000338 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
339 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000340 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
341 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000342 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
343 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000344
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000345- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200346 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
347 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000348 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000349 See doc/README.MPC866
350
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200351 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000352
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000353 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
354 of relying on the correctness of the configured
355 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
356 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
357 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200358 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000359
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100360 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
361
362 Define this option if you want to enable the
363 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
364
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600365- 85xx CPU Options:
366 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
367
368 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
369 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
370 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
371
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500372 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
373
374 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
375 tree nodes for the given platform.
376
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000377 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
378
379 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
380 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
381 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
382 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
383 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
384 purpose.
385
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000386 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
387
388 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
389 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
390 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
391
392 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
393 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
394
395 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
396 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
397
398 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
399 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
400 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
401 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
402
403 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
404 this erratum.
405
406 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
407
408 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
409 according to the A004510 workaround.
410
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000411- Generic CPU options:
412 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
413
414 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
415 values is arch specific.
416
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100417- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200418 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100419
420 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
421 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
422 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
423
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200424 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200425
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100426 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
427 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200428 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100429 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200430
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200431- MIPS CPU options:
432 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
433
434 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
435 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
436 relocation.
437
438 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
439
440 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
441 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
442 Possible values are:
443 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
444 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
445 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
446 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
447 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
448 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
449 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
450 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
451
452 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
453
454 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
455 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
456
457 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
458
459 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
460 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
461 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
462
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000463- ARM options:
464 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
465
466 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
467 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
468
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000469 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
470
471 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
472 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
473 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
474 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
475 GCC.
476
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000477- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000478 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
479
480 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
481 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
482 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
483 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
484 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
485 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
486 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000487 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100488 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000489 default environment.
490
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000491 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
492
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200493 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000494 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
495 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
496
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400497 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200498
499 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400500 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
501 concepts).
502
503 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
504 * New libfdt-based support
505 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500506 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400507
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200508 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
509 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
510 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
511 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200512 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600513 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200514
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200515 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
516 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500517
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600518 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
519
520 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
521 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000522
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500523 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
524
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200525 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500526 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
527
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200528 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
529
530 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
531 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
532 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
533 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
534 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
535 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
536
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000537 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
538
539 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
540 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
541 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
542 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
543 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
544 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
545 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
546
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100547- vxWorks boot parameters:
548
549 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
550 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
551 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
552
553 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
554 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
555 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
556 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
557
558 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
559
560 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
561
562 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
563 the defaults discussed just above.
564
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000565- Cache Configuration:
566 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
567 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
568 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
569
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000570- Cache Configuration for ARM:
571 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
572 controller
573 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
574 controller register space
575
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000576- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200577 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000578
579 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
580
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200581 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000582
583 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
584
585 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
586
587 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
588 the clock speed of the UARTs.
589
590 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
591
592 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
593 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
594 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
595
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000596 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
597
598 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
599 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
600 this variable to initialize the extra register.
601
602 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
603
604 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
605 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
606 variable to flush the UART at init time.
607
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000608
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000609- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000610 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
611 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
612 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
613 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000614
615 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
616 port routines must be defined elsewhere
617 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
618
619 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
620 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000621 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000622 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
623 (default big endian)
624 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
625 rectangle fill
626 (cf. smiLynxEM)
627 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
628 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
629 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
630 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000631 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
632 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000633 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
634 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000635 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000636 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
637 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
638 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
639 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
640 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
641 (i.e. i8042_getc)
642 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
643 (requires blink timer
644 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200645 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000646 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
647 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500648 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000649 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
650 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000651 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
652 linux_logo.h for logo.
653 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000654 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200655 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000656 the logo
657
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000658 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
659 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
660 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000661
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000662 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
663 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
664 the "silent" environment variable. See
665 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000666
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000667- Console Baudrate:
668 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
669 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200670 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
671 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000672
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100673- Console Rx buffer length
674 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
675 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100676 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100677 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
678 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
679 the SMC.
680
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000681- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200682 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
683 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
684 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
685 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
686 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
687 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
688 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200689 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200690 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000691
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200692 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
693 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000694
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000695- Safe printf() functions
696 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
697 the printf() functions. These are defined in
698 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
699 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
700 If this option is not given then these functions will
701 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
702 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
703
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000704- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
705 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
706 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
707
708 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
709 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
710 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
711 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
712 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
713 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
714 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
715 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
716 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
717 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
718 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
719 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
720
721- Autoboot Command:
722 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
723 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
724 define a command string that is automatically executed
725 when no character is read on the console interface
726 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
727
728 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000729 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
730 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
731 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000732
733 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000734 The value of these goes into the environment as
735 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
736 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200737 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000738
739- Pre-Boot Commands:
740 CONFIG_PREBOOT
741
742 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
743 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
744 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
745 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
746 entering interactive mode.
747
748 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
749 automatically generated or modified. For an example
750 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
751 modified when the user holds down a certain
752 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
753 booting the systems
754
755- Serial Download Echo Mode:
756 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
757 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
758 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
759 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
760 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
761 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
762 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
763
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500764- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000765 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
766 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200767 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000768
769- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500770 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
771 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000772 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
773 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500774 and augmenting with additional #define's
775 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000776
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500777 The default command configuration includes all commands
778 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000779
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500780 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500781 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
782 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
783 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
784 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
785 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
786 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
787 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500788 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500789 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
790 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
791 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600792 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
793 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
794 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
795 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500796 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
797 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500798 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500799 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
800 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500801 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500802 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500803 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
804 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT partition support
805 CONFIG_CMD_FDOS * Dos diskette Support
806 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
807 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -0500808 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +0000809 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500810 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
811 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
812 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
813 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
814 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all found images
815 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500816 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500817 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
818 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
819 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
820 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Mike Frysinger1ba7fd22010-12-26 12:34:49 -0500821 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +0000822 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
823 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500824 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
825 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400826 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM print md5 message digest
827 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500828 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
829 loop, loopw, mtest
830 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
831 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
832 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +0100833 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500834 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
835 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600836 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000837 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500838 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
839 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
840 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
841 host
842 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
843 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
844 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
845 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
846 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
847 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
848 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
849 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
850 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -0700851 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Alexander Hollerc6b1ee62011-01-18 09:48:08 +0100852 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400853 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +0200854 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500855 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +0000856 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +0000857 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Che-liang Chiouca366d02011-10-06 23:40:48 +0000858 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500859 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500860 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +0000861 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000862
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000863
864 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
865 support you can write:
866
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500867 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
868 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000869
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400870 Other Commands:
871 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000872
873 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500874 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000875 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
876 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
877 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
878 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
879 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
880 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000881
882
883 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
884
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000885- Device tree:
886 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
887 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
888 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
889 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
890 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
891 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
892
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000893 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
894 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000895
896 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
897 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
898 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
899 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
900 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
901 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000902
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000903 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
904 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
905 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
906 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
907
908 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
909
910 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
911 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
912 still use the individual files if you need something more
913 exotic.
914
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000915- Watchdog:
916 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
917 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000918 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
919 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
920 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
921 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
922 available, then no further board specific code should
923 be needed to use it.
924
925 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
926 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
927 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
928 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000929
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000930- U-Boot Version:
931 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
932 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
933 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
934 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e52012-08-13 15:01:14 +0200935 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
936 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000937
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000938- Real-Time Clock:
939
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500940 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000941 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
942 following options:
943
944 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
945 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +0000946 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000947 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +0000948 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000949 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +0000950 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +0000951 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +0100952 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +0000953 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200954 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +0200955 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
956 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000957
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +0000958 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
959 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
960
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600961- GPIO Support:
962 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
963 CONFIG_PCA953X_INFO - enable pca953x info command
964
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +0000965 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
966 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
967 pins supported by a particular chip.
968
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600969 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
970 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
971
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000972- Timestamp Support:
973
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000974 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
975 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
976 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500977 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000978
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000979- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
980 Zero or more of the following:
981 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
982 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
983 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
984 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
985 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
986 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
987 disk/part_efi.c
988 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000989
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100990 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
991 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +0000992 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000993
994- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000995 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
996 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000997
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000998 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
999 be performed by calling the function
1000 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1001 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001002
1003- ATAPI Support:
1004 CONFIG_ATAPI
1005
1006 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1007
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001008- LBA48 Support
1009 CONFIG_LBA48
1010
1011 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001012 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001013 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1014 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1015
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001016 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001017 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1018 Default is 32bit.
1019
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001020- SCSI Support:
1021 At the moment only there is only support for the
1022 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1023 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1024
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001025 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1026 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1027 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001028 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1029 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001030 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001031
1032- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001033 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001034 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1035
1036 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1037 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1038 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1039 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1040
1041 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1042 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1043 example with the "sspi" command.
1044
1045 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1046 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1047 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001048
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001049 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001050 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001051
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001052 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1053 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001054 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001055 write routine for first time initialisation.
1056
1057 CONFIG_TULIP
1058 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1059 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1060 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1061
1062 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1063 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1064
1065 CONFIG_NS8382X
1066 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1067
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001068- NETWORK Support (other):
1069
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001070 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1071 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1072
1073 CONFIG_RMII
1074 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1075
1076 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1077 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1078 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1079
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001080 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1081 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1082
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001083 CONFIG_DRIVER_LAN91C96
1084 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1085
1086 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1087 Define this to hold the physical address
1088 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1089
1090 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1091 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1092
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001093 CONFIG_DRIVER_SMC91111
1094 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1095
1096 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1097 Define this to hold the physical address
1098 of the device (I/O space)
1099
1100 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1101 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1102
1103 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1104 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1105 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1106
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001107 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1108 Support for davinci emac
1109
1110 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1111 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1112
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001113 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1114 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1115
1116 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1117 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1118 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1119 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1120 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1121 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1122 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1123 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1124
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001125 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001126 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1127
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001128 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001129 Define this to hold the physical address
1130 of the device (I/O space)
1131
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001132 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001133 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1134
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001135 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001136 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1137 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001138 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001139
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001140 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1141 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1142
1143 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1144 Define the number of ports to be used
1145
1146 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1147 Define the ETH PHY's address
1148
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001149 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1150 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1151
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001152- TPM Support:
1153 CONFIG_GENERIC_LPC_TPM
1154 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1155 per system is supported at this time.
1156
1157 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1158 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1159 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1160 0xfed40000.
1161
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001162- USB Support:
1163 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001164 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001165 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1166 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001167 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001168 storage devices.
1169 Note:
1170 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1171 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001172 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1173 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1174 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001175 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1176 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001177 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1178 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1179 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001180 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1181 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001182 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001183 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1184 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001185
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001186 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1187 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1188
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001189- USB Device:
1190 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1191 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1192 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001193 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001194 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1195 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001196 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001197 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1198 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1199 a Linux host by
1200 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1201 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1202 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1203 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001204
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001205 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1206 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001207
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001208 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1209 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1210 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001211
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301212 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1213 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1214 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1215 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1216 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1217 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1218 speed.
1219
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001220 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001221 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1222 be set to usbtty.
1223
1224 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001225 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001226 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001227 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001228
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001229 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001230 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001231 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001232
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001233 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001234 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001235 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001236 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1237 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1238 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1239
1240 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1241 Define this string as the name of your company for
1242 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001243
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001244 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1245 Define this string as the name of your product
1246 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1247
1248 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1249 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1250 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1251 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1252 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001253
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001254 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1255 Define this as the unique Product ID
1256 for your device
1257 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001258
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001259- ULPI Layer Support:
1260 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1261 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1262 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1263 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1264 viewport is supported.
1265 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1266 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001267
1268- MMC Support:
1269 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1270 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1271 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1272 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001273 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1274 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001275
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001276 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1277 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1278
1279 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1280 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1281
1282 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1283 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1284
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001285- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1286 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1287 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1288 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1289
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001290 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1291 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001292 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1293
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001294 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001295 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1296 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1297
1298 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001299 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001300 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1301 have not defined a custom partition
1302
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001303- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1304 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001305
1306 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1307 file in FAT formatted partition.
1308
1309 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1310 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001311
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001312- Keyboard Support:
1313 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1314
1315 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1316 support
1317
1318 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1319 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1320 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1321 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1322 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1323
1324- Video support:
1325 CONFIG_VIDEO
1326
1327 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1328 video).
1329
1330 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1331
1332 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1333
1334 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001335 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001336 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1337 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1338 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001339
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001340 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001341 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001342 are possible:
1343 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001344 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001345
1346 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1347 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1348 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1349 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1350 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1351 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1352 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001353 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1354
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001355 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001356 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001357
1358
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001359 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001360 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001361 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1362 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1363
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001364 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001365 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001366 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1367 support, and should also define these other macros:
1368
1369 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1370 CONFIG_VIDEO
1371 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1372 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1373 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1374 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1375 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1376 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1377
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001378 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1379 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1380 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1381 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001382
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001383- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001384 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001385
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001386 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1387 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1388 defined in your board-specific files.
1389 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001390
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001391- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1392
1393 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1394 display); also select one of the supported displays
1395 by defining one of these:
1396
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001397 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1398
1399 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1400
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001401 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001402
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001403 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001404
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001405 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001406
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001407 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1408 Active, color, single scan.
1409
1410 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1411
1412 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001413 Active, color, single scan.
1414
1415 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1416
1417 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1418 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1419
1420 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1421
1422 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1423 Active, color, single scan.
1424
1425 CONFIG_HLD1045
1426
1427 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1428 Active, color, single scan.
1429
1430 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1431
1432 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1433 or
1434 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1435 or
1436 Hitachi SP14Q002
1437
1438 320x240. Black & white.
1439
1440 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001441 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001442
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001443- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001444
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001445 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1446 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1447 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001448 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001449 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1450 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1451 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1452 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001453
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001454 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1455
1456 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1457 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1458 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1459 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1460 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1461 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1462
1463 Example:
1464 setenv splashpos m,m
1465 => image at center of screen
1466
1467 setenv splashpos 30,20
1468 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1469
1470 setenv splashpos -10,m
1471 => vertically centered image
1472 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1473
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001474- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1475
1476 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1477 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1478 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1479
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001480- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1481
1482 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1483 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1484 bmp command.
1485
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001486- Compression support:
1487 CONFIG_BZIP2
1488
1489 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1490 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1491 compressed images are supported.
1492
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001493 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001494 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001495 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001496
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001497 CONFIG_LZMA
1498
1499 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1500 images is included.
1501
1502 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1503 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1504 formula:
1505
1506 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1507
1508 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1509 and Literal pos bits.
1510
1511 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1512 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1513 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1514 a very small buffer.
1515
1516 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1517 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001518 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001519
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001520- MII/PHY support:
1521 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1522
1523 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1524
1525 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1526
1527 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1528
1529 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1530
1531 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001532 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001533
1534 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1535
1536 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1537 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1538 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1539 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1540
1541 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1542
1543 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1544 command issued before MII status register can be read
1545
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001546- Ethernet address:
1547 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001548 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001549 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1550 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001551 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1552 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001553
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001554 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1555 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001556 is not determined automatically.
1557
1558- IP address:
1559 CONFIG_IPADDR
1560
1561 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001562 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001563 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001564 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001565
1566- Server IP address:
1567 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1568
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001569 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001570 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001571 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001572
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001573 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1574
1575 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1576 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1577
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001578- Gateway IP address:
1579 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1580
1581 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1582 default router where packets to other networks are
1583 sent to.
1584 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1585
1586- Subnet mask:
1587 CONFIG_NETMASK
1588
1589 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1590 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1591 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1592 forwarded through a router.
1593 (Environment variable "netmask")
1594
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001595- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1596 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1597
1598 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1599 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001600 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001601 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1602 multicast group.
1603
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001604- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1605 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1606
1607 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1608 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1609 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1610 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1611 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1612 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1613 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1614 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001615 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001616
1617 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1618 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1619 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1620 4th and following
1621 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1622
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001623- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001624 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1625 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001626
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001627 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1628 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1629 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1630 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1631 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1632 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1633 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1634 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1635 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1636 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1637 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1638 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001639 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001640
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001641 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1642 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001643
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001644 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1645 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1646 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1647 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1648 is not available.
1649
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001650 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1651 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1652 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1653 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1654 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1655 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1656 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001657 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001658
1659 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1660 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1661 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001662 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001663 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1664 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001665
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001666 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1667
1668 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1669 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1670 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1671 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1672 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1673 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1674 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1675 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1676 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1677 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1678 this delay.
1679
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001680 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1681 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1682 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1683 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1684 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1685
1686 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1687
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001688 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001689 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001690
1691 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1692
1693 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1694
1695 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1696 of the device.
1697
1698 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1699
1700 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1701 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001702 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001703
1704 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1705
1706 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1707 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1708
1709 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1710
1711 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1712
1713 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1714
1715 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1716
1717 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1718
1719 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1720
1721 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1722
1723 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1724 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1725
1726 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1727
1728 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1729
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001730- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
1731
1732 Several configurations allow to display the current
1733 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1734 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1735 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1736 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1737 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
1738 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
1739 feature in U-Boot.
1740
1741- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
1742
1743 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
1744 on those systems that support this (optional)
1745 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
1746
1747- I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C | CONFIG_SOFT_I2C
1748
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001749 These enable I2C serial bus commands. Defining either of
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001750 (but not both of) CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C will
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001751 include the appropriate I2C driver for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001752
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001753 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001754 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001755 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
1756 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001757 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001758
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001759 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001760
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001761 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C configures u-boot to use a software (aka
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001762 bit-banging) driver instead of CPM or similar hardware
1763 support for I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001764
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001765 There are several other quantities that must also be
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001766 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001767
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001768 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001769 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001770 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001771 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001772
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001773 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02001774 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001775 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
1776 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
1777 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001778
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05001779 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
1780
1781 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1782 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1783 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
1784 commands until the slave device responds.
1785
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001786 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001787
1788 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SOFT_I2C)
1789 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1790 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001791
1792 I2C_INIT
1793
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001794 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001795 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001796
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001797 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001798
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001799 I2C_PORT
1800
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001801 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
1802 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
1803 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001804
1805 I2C_ACTIVE
1806
1807 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1808 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1809 define can be null.
1810
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001811 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1812
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001813 I2C_TRISTATE
1814
1815 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1816 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1817 define can be null.
1818
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001819 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1820
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001821 I2C_READ
1822
1823 Code that returns TRUE if the I2C data line is high,
1824 FALSE if it is low.
1825
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001826 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1827
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001828 I2C_SDA(bit)
1829
1830 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1831 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1832
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001833 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001834 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001835 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001836
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001837 I2C_SCL(bit)
1838
1839 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1840 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1841
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001842 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001843 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001844 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001845
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001846 I2C_DELAY
1847
1848 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1849 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001850 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001851 like:
1852
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001853 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001854
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04001855 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
1856
1857 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
1858 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
1859 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
1860 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
1861
1862 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
1863 the generic GPIO functions.
1864
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001865 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001866
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001867 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1868 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1869 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
1870 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
1871 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
1872 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
1873 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
1874 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001875
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04001876 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
1877
1878 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
1879 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
1880 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
1881 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
1882 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
1883 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
1884 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
1885 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
1886
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001887 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
1888
1889 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
1890 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
1891 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
1892
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001893 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
1894
1895 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001896 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
1897 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001898 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
1899
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001900 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001901
1902 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001903 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05001904 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
1905 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001906
1907 e.g.
1908 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001909 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001910
1911 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
1912
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001913 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001914 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001915
1916 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
1917
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001918 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001919
1920 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
1921 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
1922
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001923 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001924
1925 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
1926 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
1927
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001928 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001929
1930 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
1931 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
1932
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001933 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07001934
1935 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
1936 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
1937 specified DTT device.
1938
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001939 CONFIG_FSL_I2C
1940
1941 Define this option if you want to use Freescale's I2C driver in
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001942 drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001943
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001944 CONFIG_I2C_MUX
1945
1946 Define this option if you have I2C devices reached over 1 .. n
1947 I2C Muxes like the pca9544a. This option addes a new I2C
1948 Command "i2c bus [muxtype:muxaddr:muxchannel]" which adds a
1949 new I2C Bus to the existing I2C Busses. If you select the
1950 new Bus with "i2c dev", u-bbot sends first the commandos for
1951 the muxes to activate this new "bus".
1952
1953 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS must be also defined, to use this
1954 feature!
1955
1956 Example:
1957 Adding a new I2C Bus reached over 2 pca9544a muxes
1958 The First mux with address 70 and channel 6
1959 The Second mux with address 71 and channel 4
1960
1961 => i2c bus pca9544a:70:6:pca9544a:71:4
1962
1963 Use the "i2c bus" command without parameter, to get a list
1964 of I2C Busses with muxes:
1965
1966 => i2c bus
1967 Busses reached over muxes:
1968 Bus ID: 2
1969 reached over Mux(es):
1970 pca9544a@70 ch: 4
1971 Bus ID: 3
1972 reached over Mux(es):
1973 pca9544a@70 ch: 6
1974 pca9544a@71 ch: 4
1975 =>
1976
1977 If you now switch to the new I2C Bus 3 with "i2c dev 3"
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00001978 u-boot first sends the command to the mux@70 to enable
1979 channel 6, and then the command to the mux@71 to enable
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001980 the channel 4.
1981
1982 After that, you can use the "normal" i2c commands as
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00001983 usual to communicate with your I2C devices behind
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001984 the 2 muxes.
1985
1986 This option is actually implemented for the bitbanging
1987 algorithm in common/soft_i2c.c and for the Hardware I2C
1988 Bus on the MPC8260. But it should be not so difficult
1989 to add this option to other architectures.
1990
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06001991 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
1992
1993 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
1994 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
1995 between writing the address pointer and reading the
1996 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
1997 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
1998 devices can use either method, but some require one or
1999 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002001- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2002
2003 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2004 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2005 D/As on the SACSng board)
2006
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002007 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2008
2009 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2010 only SH7757 is supported.
2011
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002012 CONFIG_SPI_X
2013
2014 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2015 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2016
2017 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2018
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002019 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2020 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2021 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2022 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2023 defined, the board configuration must define several
2024 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2025 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002026
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002027 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2028
2029 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2030 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2031 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002032 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002033 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2034
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002035 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2036
2037 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002038 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002039
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002040- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2041
2042 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2043
2044 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2045
2046 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2047 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2048
2049 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2050
2051 Enables support for FPGA family.
2052 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2053
2054 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002055
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002056 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002057
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002058 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002059
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002060 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002061
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002062 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002063
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002064 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2065 status by the configuration function. This option
2066 will require a board or device specific function to
2067 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002068
2069 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2070
2071 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2072 configuration driver.
2073
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002074 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002075 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2076
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002077 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002078
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002079 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2080 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2081 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2082 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002083
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002084 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002085
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002086 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2087 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2088 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002089 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002090
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002091 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002092
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002093 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002094 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002095
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002096 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002097
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002098 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002099 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002100
2101- Configuration Management:
2102 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2103
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002104 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2105 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002106
2107- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2108
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002109 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2110 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002111 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002112 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2113 protects these variables from casual modification by
2114 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2115 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002116 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002117
2118 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2119 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002120 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002121 these parameters.
2122
2123 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2124 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002125 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002126 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2127 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2128 read-only.]
2129
2130- Protected RAM:
2131 CONFIG_PRAM
2132
2133 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2134 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2135 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2136 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2137 this default value by defining an environment
2138 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2139 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2140 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2141 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2142 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2143 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2144 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2145
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002146 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002147 saveenv
2148
2149 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2150 either, which results in a memory region that will
2151 not be affected by reboots.
2152
2153 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2154 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2155 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2156 following board configurations are known to be
2157 "pRAM-clean":
2158
2159 ETX094, IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2160 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON, LANTEC,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002161 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002162
2163- Error Recovery:
2164 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2165
2166 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2167 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2168 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002169 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002170 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2171 useful during development since you can try to debug
2172 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2173
2174 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2175
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002176 This variable defines the number of retries for
2177 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2178 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2179 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002180
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002181 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2182
2183 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2184
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002185 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2186
2187 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2188 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2189 try longer timeout such as
2190 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2191
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002192- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002193 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002194
2195 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2196
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002197 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2198 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002199
2200
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002201 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002202
2203 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2204 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2205 powerful command line syntax like
2206 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2207 constructs ("shell scripts").
2208
2209 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2210 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2211
2212
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002213 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002214
2215 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2216 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2217 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2218
2219 Note:
2220
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002221 In the current implementation, the local variables
2222 space and global environment variables space are
2223 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2224 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2225 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2226 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2227 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002228
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002229 Global environment variables are those you use
2230 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2231 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2232 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002233
2234 To store commands and special characters in a
2235 variable, please use double quotation marks
2236 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2237 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2238 symbols.
2239
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002240- Commandline Editing and History:
2241 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2242
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002243 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002244 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002245
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002246- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002247 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2248
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002249 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2250 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002251 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002252
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002253 For example, place something like this in your
2254 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002255
2256 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2257 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2258 "myvar2=value2\0"
2259
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002260 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2261 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2262 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2263 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002264 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002265 You better know what you are doing here.
2266
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002267 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2268 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002269 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002270 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002271
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002272 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2273
2274 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2275 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2276 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2277
2278 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2279
2280 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2281 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2282 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2283 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2284 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2285
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002286- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002287 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2288
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002289 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2290 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2291 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002292
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002293- Serial Flash support
2294 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2295
2296 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2297 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2298
2299 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2300 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2301 commands.
2302
2303 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2304 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2305 flash is present on the system.
2306
2307 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2308 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2309 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2310 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2311
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002312- SystemACE Support:
2313 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2314
2315 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2316 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002317 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002318 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002319
2320 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002321 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002322
2323 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2324 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2325
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002326- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2327 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2328
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002329 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002330 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002331 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002332 number generator is used.
2333
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002334 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2335 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2336 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2337
2338 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002339 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2340 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2341 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2342 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2343 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2344 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2345
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002346- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002347 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2348
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002349 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2350 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2351 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2352 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2353 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2354 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002355
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00002356- Detailed boot stage timing
2357 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
2358 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
2359 of the boot process.
2360
2361 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
2362 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
2363 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
2364 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
2365 the limit, recording will stop.
2366
2367 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
2368 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
2369
2370 Timer summary in microseconds:
2371 Mark Elapsed Stage
2372 0 0 reset
2373 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
2374 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
2375 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
2376 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
2377 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
2378 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
2379 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
2380
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002381Legacy uImage format:
2382
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002383 Arg Where When
2384 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002385 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002386 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002387 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002388 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002389 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002390 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2391 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2392 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002393 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002394 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2395 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2396 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2397 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002398 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002399 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002400
2401 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2402 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2403 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2404 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2405 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2406 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2407 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002408 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002409 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2410 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2411
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002412 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002413
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002414 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd52004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002415 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2416 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002417
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002418 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2419 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2420 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2421 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2422 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2423 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2424 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2425 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2426 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2427 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2428 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2429 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2430 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2431 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2432 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2433 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2434 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2435 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2436 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2437 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2438 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2439 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2440 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2441 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2442 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2443 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2444 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2445 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2446 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2447 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2448 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2449 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2450 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2451 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2452 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2453 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2454 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2455 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2456 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2457 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2458 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2459 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2460 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2461 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2462 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2463 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2464 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002465
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002466 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002467
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002468 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002469 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2470 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00002471
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002472 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
2473 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002474 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002475 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
2476 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2477 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002478 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2479 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002480 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002481
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002482FIT uImage format:
2483
2484 Arg Where When
2485 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2486 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2487 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2488 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2489 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2490 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002491 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002492 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2493 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2494 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2495 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2496 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002497 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2498 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002499 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2500 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2501 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2502 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2503 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2504 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2505 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2506 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2507
2508 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2509 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2510 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002511 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002512 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2513 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2514 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2515 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2516 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2517 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2518 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2519 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2520 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2521 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2522 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2523 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2524
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002525 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002526 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2527
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002528 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002529 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2530
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002531 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002532 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2533
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002534- Standalone program support:
2535 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2536
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002537 This option defines a board specific value for the
2538 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2539 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002540 settings.
2541
2542- Frame Buffer Address:
2543 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2544
2545 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
2546 address for frame buffer.
2547 Then system will reserve the frame buffer address to
2548 defined address instead of lcd_setmem (this function
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002549 grabs the memory for frame buffer by panel's size).
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002550
2551 Please see board_init_f function.
2552
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002553- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2554 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2555 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2556 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2557
2558 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2559 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2560
2561- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
2562 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
2563
2564 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
2565 Needed for mtdparts command support.
2566
2567 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
2568
2569 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
2570 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
2571
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002572- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002573 CONFIG_SPL
2574 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002575
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002576 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2577 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
2578
2579 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
2580 Maximum binary size (text, data and rodata) of the SPL binary.
2581
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002582 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2583 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002584
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002585 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
2586 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
2587
2588 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
2589 Maximum binary size of the BSS section of the SPL binary.
2590
2591 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
2592 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
2593
2594 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
2595 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
2596
2597 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
2598 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002599
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07002600 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
2601 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
2602 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
2603 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
2604
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07002605 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
2606 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
2607 about the running system.
2608
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002609 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
2610 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002611
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002612 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
2613 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002614
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002615 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
2616 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002617
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002618 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
2619 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002620
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002621 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
2622 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002623
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002624 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
2625 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
2626 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
2627 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
2628 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
2629
2630 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
2631 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
2632
2633 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
2634 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
2635
2636 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
2637 Support for drivers/mtd/nand/libnand.o in SPL binary
2638
2639 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
2640 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
2641 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
2642 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
2643 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
2644 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
2645 to read U-Boot with CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
2646
2647 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
2648 Location in NAND for CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE to read U-Boot
2649 from.
2650
2651 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
2652 Location in memory for CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE to load U-Boot
2653 to.
2654
2655 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
2656 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
2657 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
2658
2659 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
2660 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
2661 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
2662
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002663 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
2664 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002665
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002666 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
2667 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002668
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002669 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
2670 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002671
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002672 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
2673 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002674
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002675Modem Support:
2676--------------
2677
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02002678[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002679
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002680- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002681 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
2682
2683- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
2684 CONFIG_HWFLOW
2685
2686- Modem debug support:
2687 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
2688
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002689 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
2690 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002691
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002692- Interrupt support (PPC):
2693
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002694 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2695 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002696 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002697 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002698 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002699 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002700 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002701 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2702 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2703 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002704
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002705- General:
2706
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002707 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
2708 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
2709 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002710 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002711 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
2712 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
2713 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002714
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002715 If there are no modem init strings in the
2716 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
2717 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002718 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002719
2720 See also: doc/README.Modem
2721
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00002722Board initialization settings:
2723------------------------------
2724
2725During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
2726to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
2727before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
2728following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
2729architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
2730typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
2731
2732- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
2733- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
2734- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
2735- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002736
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002737Configuration Settings:
2738-----------------------
2739
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002740- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002741 undefine this when you're short of memory.
2742
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06002743- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
2744 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
2745
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002746- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002747 prompt for user input.
2748
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002749- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002750
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002751- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002752
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002753- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002754
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002755- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002756 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
2757 booted
2758
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002759- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002760 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
2761
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002762- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002763 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002764
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002765- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002766 If the board specific function
2767 extern int overwrite_console (void);
2768 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002769 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
2770
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002771- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002772 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002773
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002774- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002775 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
2776
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002777- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002778 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
2779 simple memory test.
2780
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002781- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002782 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002783
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002784- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00002785 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
2786 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
2787
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002788- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
2789 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002790 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002791 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002792 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
2793 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
2794 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002795 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002796 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002797 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002798
2799 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
2800 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
2801 be touched.
2802
2803 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
2804 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
2805 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
2806 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
2807 problems.
2808
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002809- CONFIG_SYS_TFTP_LOADADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002810 Default load address for network file downloads
2811
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002812- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002813 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
2814
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002815- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002816 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
2817
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002818- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002819 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
2820 Cogent motherboard)
2821
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002822- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002823 Physical start address of Flash memory.
2824
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002825- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002826 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
2827 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02002828 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002829 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002830
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002831- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002832 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
2833 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
2834 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
2835 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002836
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002837- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002838 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
2839
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002840- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002841 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
2842 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002843 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002844 to adjust this setting to your needs.
2845
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002846- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002847 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
2848 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02002849 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
2850 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
2851 enviroment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
2852 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002853 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00002854 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
2855 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
2856 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002857
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06002858- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
2859 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
2860 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
2861 is enabled.
2862
2863- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
2864 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
2865 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2866
2867- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
2868 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
2869 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2870
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002871- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002872 Max number of Flash memory banks
2873
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002874- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002875 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
2876
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002877- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002878 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
2879
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002880- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002881 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
2882
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002883- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002884 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
2885
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002886- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002887 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
2888
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002889- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002890 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
2891 instead of U-Boot software protection.
2892
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002893- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002894
2895 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
2896 without this option such a download has to be
2897 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
2898 copy from RAM to flash.
2899
2900 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
2901 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002902 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
2903 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002904 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
2905
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002906- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002907 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002908 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
2909
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02002910- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002911 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
2912 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002913
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01002914- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
2915 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
2916 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
2917 to the MTD layer.
2918
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002919- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02002920 Use buffered writes to flash.
2921
2922- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
2923 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
2924 write commands.
2925
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002926- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01002927 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
2928 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
2929 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
2930 optionally available.
2931
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05002932- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
2933 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
2934 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
2935 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
2936
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002937- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002938 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
2939 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002940 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
2941 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002942 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002943 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
2944
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002945- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
2946
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02002947 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
2948 internally to store the environment settings. The default
2949 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
2950 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
2951 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002952
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002953The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
2954of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
2955following configurations:
2956
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00002957- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
2958
2959 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
2960 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
2961
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02002962- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002963
2964 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
2965
2966 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
2967 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
2968 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
2969 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
2970 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
2971 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
2972 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
2973 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
2974 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
2975 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
2976 between U-Boot and the environment.
2977
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002978 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002979
2980 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
2981 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
2982 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
2983 for this sector is given here.
2984
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002985 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002986
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002987 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002988
2989 This is just another way to specify the start address of
2990 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002991 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002992
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002993 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002994
2995 Size of the sector containing the environment.
2996
2997
2998 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
2999 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
3000 the environment.
3001
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003002 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003003
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003004 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003005 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003006 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
3007 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
3008
3009 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
3010 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
3011 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
3012 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
3013 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
3014 updating the environment in flash makes it always
3015 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
3016 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
3017 RAM, your target system will be dead.
3018
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003019 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
3020 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003021
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003022 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003023 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00003024 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003025 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003026
3027BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
3028source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
3029accordingly!
3030
3031
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02003032- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003033
3034 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
3035 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
3036 environment.
3037
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003038 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3039 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003040
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003041 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003042 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
3043 can just be read and written to, without any special
3044 provision.
3045
3046BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
3047in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003048console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003049U-Boot will hang.
3050
3051Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
3052environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
3053keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
3054to save the current settings.
3055
3056
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02003057- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003058
3059 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
3060 device and a driver for it.
3061
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003062 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3063 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003064
3065 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
3066 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
3067
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003068 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003069 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
3070 The default address is zero.
3071
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003072 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003073 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
3074 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
3075 would require six bits.
3076
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003077 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003078 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003079 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003080
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003081 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003082 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
3083 that this is NOT the chip address length!
3084
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003085 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003086 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
3087 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
3088 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
3089 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
3090 byte chips.
3091
3092 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
3093 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
3094 in the chip address.
3095
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003096 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003097 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
3098
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003099 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
3100 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
3101 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
3102
3103 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
3104 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
3105 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
3106 EEPROM. For example:
3107
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +02003108 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS "pca9547:70:d\0"
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003109
3110 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
3111 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003112
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003113- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003114
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003115 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003116 want to use for the environment.
3117
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003118 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3119 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3120 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003121
3122 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
3123 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
3124 at the specified address.
3125
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003126- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
3127
3128 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
3129 want to use for the local device's environment.
3130
3131 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3132 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
3133
3134 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
3135 environment area within the remote memory space. The
3136 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003137 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003138
3139BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
3140"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003141environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3142but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003143
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003144- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003145
3146 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
3147 for the environment.
3148
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003149 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3150 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003151
3152 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003153 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
3154 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003155
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003156 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003157
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003158 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003159 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
3160 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003161 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003162 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003163
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003164 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
3165
3166 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
3167 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
3168 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
3169 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
3170 the range to be avoided.
3171
3172 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
3173
3174 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
3175 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
3176 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
3177 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
3178 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003179
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003180- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3181
3182 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3183 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3184 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3185
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003186- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003187
3188 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
3189 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
3190 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
3191 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
3192 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
3193 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
3194 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
3195
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07003196Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003197has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02003198created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003199until then to read environment variables.
3200
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003201The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
3202is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
3203with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
3204necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
3205"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
3206have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003207
3208Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
3209the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003210use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003211
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003212- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003213 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003214
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003215 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003216 also needs to be defined.
3217
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003218- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003219 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003220
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08003221- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
3222 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
3223 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
3224 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
3225 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
3226 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
3227
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003228Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00003229---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003230
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003231- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003232 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
3233
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003234- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003235 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00003236
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003237 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
3238 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
3239 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003240
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003241- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
3242 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
3243 PowerPC SOCs.
3244
3245- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
3246 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
3247 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
3248
3249 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
3250 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
3251
3252- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
3253 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
3254 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003255 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003256 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
3257 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
3258 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
3259
3260 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
3261 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
3262
3263- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003264 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
3265 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003266 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3267 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3268
3269- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
3270 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
3271 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3272 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3273
3274- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
3275 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
3276 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
3277
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003278- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003279 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003280
3281 the default drive number (default value 0)
3282
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003283 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003284
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003285 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003286 (default value 1)
3287
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003288 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003289
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003290 defines the offset of register from address. It
3291 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003292 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003293
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003294 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
3295 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003296 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003297
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003298 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003299 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
3300 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
3301 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
3302 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003303
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003304- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
3305 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
3306 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
3307 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
3308 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
3309 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
3310 is requierd.
3311
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003312- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003313 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00003314 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003315
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003316- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003317
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00003318 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003319 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
3320 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
3321 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
3322 will become available only after programming the
3323 memory controller and running certain initialization
3324 sequences.
3325
3326 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
3327 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
3328 - MPC824X: data cache
3329 - PPC4xx: data cache
3330
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003331- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003332
3333 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003334 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3335 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003336 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003337 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003338 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
3339 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3340 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003341
3342 Note:
3343 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3344 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003345 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003346 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3347 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3348
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003349- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003350
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003351- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003352
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003353- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003354
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003355- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003356
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003357- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003358
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003359- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003360
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003361- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003362 SDRAM timing
3363
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003364- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003365 periodic timer for refresh
3366
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003367- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003368
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003369- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3370 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3371 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3372 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003373 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3374
3375- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003376 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3377 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003378 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3379
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003380- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
3381 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003382 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
3383 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
3384
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003385- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003386 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3387 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
3388
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003389- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01003390 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3391 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
3392
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003393- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003394 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3395 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
3396
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003397- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003398 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
3399 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
3400 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
3401
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003402- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003403 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
3404 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
3405 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
3406 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00003407
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003408- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3409 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
3410 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
3411 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3412 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
3413 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
3414 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
3415 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003416 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00003417
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01003418- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
3419 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
3420 required.
3421
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003422- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
3423 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
3424 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
3425 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
3426 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
3427 by coreboot or similar.
3428
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003429- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3430 Chip has SRIO or not
3431
3432- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3433 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3434
3435- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3436 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3437
3438- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3439 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3440
3441- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3442 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3443
3444- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3445 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3446
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003447- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_16
3448 Defined to tell the NDFC that the NAND chip is using a
3449 16 bit bus.
3450
3451- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3452 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3453 a default value will be used.
3454
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003455- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003456 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3457 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3458
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003459 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3460 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3461
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003462- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003463 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3464 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3465 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003466
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003467- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3468 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3469 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3470 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3471 header files or board specific files.
3472
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003473- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3474 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3475
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003476- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003477 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3478 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003479
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003480- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
3481 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
3482
3483- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
3484 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00003485 to the given FEC; i. e.
3486 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003487 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
3488
3489 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
3490
3491- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
3492 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
3493 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
3494
3495- CONFIG_RMII
3496 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3497 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3498 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3499
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003500- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3501 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3502 The syntax is:
3503
3504 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3505
3506 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3507 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3508 area should have.
3509
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003510- CONFIG_LOOPW
3511 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003512 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003513
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003514- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3515 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3516 "md/mw" commands.
3517 Examples:
3518
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003519 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003520 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3521
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003522 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003523 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3524
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003525 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003526 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003527
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003528- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003529 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003530 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3531 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3532 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003533
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003534 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3535 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3536 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3537 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003538
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003539- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003540 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3541 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3542 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003543
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00003544- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
3545 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
3546 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
3547 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
3548 conditions but may increase the binary size.
3549
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003550Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
3551-----------------------------------
3552
3553The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
3554loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
3555This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3556are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3557within that device.
3558
3559- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_ADDR
3560 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
3561 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3562 is also specified.
3563
3564- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
3565 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
3566 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
3567 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
3568 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
3569
3570- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
3571 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
3572 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
3573 virtual address in NOR flash.
3574
3575- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
3576 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
3577 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
3578
3579- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
3580 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
3581 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3582
3583- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
3584 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
3585 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3586
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00003587- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
3588 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
3589 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003590 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
3591 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
3592 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003593
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003594Building the Software:
3595======================
3596
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003597Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3598and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3599all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3600(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3601recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3602which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003603
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003604If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3605have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3606you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3607Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3608necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003609
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003610 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3611 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003612
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003613Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3614 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3615 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3616 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3617
3618 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3619
3620 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3621 be executed on computers running Windows.
3622
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003623U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3624sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003625is done by typing:
3626
3627 make NAME_config
3628
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003629where "NAME_config" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003630rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003631
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003632Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3633 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3634 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3635 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003636 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003637
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003638 make TQM823L_config
3639 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003640
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003641 make TQM823L_LCD_config
3642 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003643
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003644 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003645
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003646
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003647Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
3648images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003649
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003650- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
3651- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
3652- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003653
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003654By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
3655in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
3656this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
3657
36581. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
3659
3660 make O=/tmp/build distclean
3661 make O=/tmp/build NAME_config
3662 make O=/tmp/build all
3663
36642. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
3665
3666 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
3667 make distclean
3668 make NAME_config
3669 make all
3670
3671Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
3672variable.
3673
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003674
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003675Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
3676for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
3677native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003678
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003679
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003680If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
3681to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
3682steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003683
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000036841. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003685 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
3686 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000036872. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
3688 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
3689 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
36903. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
3691 your board
36923. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
3693 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
36944. Run "make <board>_config" with your new name.
36955. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
3696 to be installed on your target system.
36976. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
3698 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003699
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003700
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003701Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
3702==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003703
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003704If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
3705or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003706provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
3707the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003708official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003709
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003710But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
3711cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003712the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
3713just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003714for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
3715select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
3716environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
3717you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003718
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003719 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003720
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003721or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003722
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003723 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003724
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003725When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
3726U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
3727setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
3728built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
3729<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
3730location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
3731variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003732
3733 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
3734 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
3735 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
3736
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003737With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
3738log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
3739during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003740
3741
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003742See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003743
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003744
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003745Monitor Commands - Overview:
3746============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003747
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003748go - start application at address 'addr'
3749run - run commands in an environment variable
3750bootm - boot application image from memory
3751bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00003752bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003753tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
3754 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
3755 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00003756tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003757rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
3758diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
3759loads - load S-Record file over serial line
3760loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
3761md - memory display
3762mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
3763nm - memory modify (constant address)
3764mw - memory write (fill)
3765cp - memory copy
3766cmp - memory compare
3767crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05003768i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003769sspi - SPI utility commands
3770base - print or set address offset
3771printenv- print environment variables
3772setenv - set environment variables
3773saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
3774protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
3775erase - erase FLASH memory
3776flinfo - print FLASH memory information
3777bdinfo - print Board Info structure
3778iminfo - print header information for application image
3779coninfo - print console devices and informations
3780ide - IDE sub-system
3781loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003782loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003783mtest - simple RAM test
3784icache - enable or disable instruction cache
3785dcache - enable or disable data cache
3786reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
3787echo - echo args to console
3788version - print monitor version
3789help - print online help
3790? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003791
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003792
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003793Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
3794========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003795
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003796TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003797
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003798For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003799
3800
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003801Environment Variables:
3802======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003803
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003804U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
3805can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003806
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003807Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
3808"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
3809without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
3810environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
3811working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
3812environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003813
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003814Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
3815
3816List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003817
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003818 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003819
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003820 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003821
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003822 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003823
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003824 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003825
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003826 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003827
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003828 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3829 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3830 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
3831 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
3832 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
3833 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003834 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
3835 bootm_mapsize.
3836
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003837 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003838 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
3839 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
3840 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
3841 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
3842 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
3843 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003844
3845 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3846 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3847 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
3848 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
3849 environment variable.
3850
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02003851 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
3852 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
3853 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
3854
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003855 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
3856 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
3857 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
3858 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003859
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003860 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
3861 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
3862 be automatically started (by internally calling
3863 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003864
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003865 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
3866 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
3867 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
3868 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
3869 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003870
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003871 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
3872 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00003873 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
3874 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
3875 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
3876 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
3877 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
3878 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
3879 access it during the boot procedure.
3880
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003881 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
3882 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
3883 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
3884 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
3885 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
3886 must be accessible by the kernel.
3887
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00003888 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
3889 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
3890 defined.
3891
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00003892 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
3893 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
3894 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
3895 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
3896 it must be saved and board must be reset.
3897
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003898 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
3899 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
3900 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
3901 is usually what you want since it allows for
3902 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
3903 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003904 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003905 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
3906 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
3907 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
3908 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003909
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003910 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
3911 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
3912 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
3913 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
3914 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
3915 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003916
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003917 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003918
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003919 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
3920 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
3921 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
3922 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
3923 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
3924 boot time on your system, but requires that this
3925 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00003926
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003927 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003928
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003929 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
3930 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003931
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003932 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003933
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003934 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00003935
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003936 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003937
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003938 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003939
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003940 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003941
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003942 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003943
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003944 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
3945 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003946
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02003947 => setenv ethact FEC
3948 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
3949 => setenv ethact SCC
3950 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003951
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01003952 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
3953 available network interfaces.
3954 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
3955
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003956 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003957 either succeed or fail without retrying.
3958 When set to "once" the network operation will
3959 fail when all the available network interfaces
3960 are tried once without success.
3961 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
3962 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003963
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01003964 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01003965
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003966 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003967 UDP source port.
3968
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003969 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
3970 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
3971
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003972 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
3973 we use the TFTP server's default block size
3974
3975 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
3976 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
3977 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
3978 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
3979 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
3980 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
3981 with unreliable TFTP servers.
3982
3983 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003984 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003985 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003986
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00003987The following image location variables contain the location of images
3988used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
3989not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
3990variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
3991server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
3992loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
3993flash or offset in NAND flash.
3994
3995*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
3996boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
3997boards use these variables for other purposes.
3998
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003999Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
4000----- --------- ----------- --------------
4001u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
4002Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
4003device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
4004ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004005
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004006The following environment variables may be used and automatically
4007updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
4008depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004009
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004010 bootfile - see above
4011 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
4012 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
4013 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
4014 hostname - Target hostname
4015 ipaddr - see above
4016 netmask - Subnet Mask
4017 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
4018 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004019
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004020
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004021There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004022
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004023 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
4024 as type string and/or serial number
4025 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004026
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004027These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
4028the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
4029once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004030
4031
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004032Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004033
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004034 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
4035 with the "version" command. This variable is
4036 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004037
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004038
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004039Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
4040only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004041
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004042
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004043Command Line Parsing:
4044=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004045
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004046There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
4047the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004048
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004049Old, simple command line parser:
4050--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004051
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004052- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
4053- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004054- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004055- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
4056 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004057 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004058- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
4059 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004060
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004061Hush shell:
4062-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004063
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004064- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
4065 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
4066 until...do...done, ...
4067- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
4068 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
4069 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
4070 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004071
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004072General rules:
4073--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004074
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004075(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
4076 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
4077 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
4078 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004079
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004080(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004081 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004082 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
4083 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004084
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004085Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
4086=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004087
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004088Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004089such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
4090"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004091
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004092Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
4093MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
4094"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004095
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004096If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
4097in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
4098ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
4099variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004100
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004101o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
4102 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004103
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004104o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
4105 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
4106 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004107
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004108o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
4109 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004110
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004111o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
4112 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
4113 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004114
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004115o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
4116 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004117
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004118If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004119will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004120may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
4121The naming convention is as follows:
4122"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004123
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004124Image Formats:
4125==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004126
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01004127U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
4128images in two formats:
4129
4130New uImage format (FIT)
4131-----------------------
4132
4133Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
4134to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
4135components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
4136SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
4137
4138
4139Old uImage format
4140-----------------
4141
4142Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
4143preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
4144details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004145
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004146* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
4147 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05004148 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
4149 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
4150 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02004151* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004152 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
4153 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004154* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
4155* Load Address
4156* Entry Point
4157* Image Name
4158* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004159
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004160The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
4161and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
4162CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004163
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004164
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004165Linux Support:
4166==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004167
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004168Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
4169easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
4170U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004171
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004172U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
4173special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
4174"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
4175instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
4176serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004177
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004178- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
4179 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
4180 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004181
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004182- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
4183 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004184
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004185- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
4186 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
4187 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
4188 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
4189 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
4190 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004191
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004192
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004193Linux HOWTO:
4194============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004195
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004196Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
4197---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004198
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004199U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
4200configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
4201(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
4202Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004203
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004204But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004205
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004206Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
4207include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02004208Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
4209and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004210as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004211
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004212
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004213Configuring the Linux kernel:
4214-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004215
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004216No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
4217device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004218
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004219
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004220Building a Linux Image:
4221-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004222
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004223With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
4224not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
4225"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
4226U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
4227which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
4228100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004229
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004230Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004231
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004232 make TQM850L_config
4233 make oldconfig
4234 make dep
4235 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004236
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004237The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
4238encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
4239CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004240
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004241* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004242
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004243* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004244
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004245 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
4246 -R .note -R .comment \
4247 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004248
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004249* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004250
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004251 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004252
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004253* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004254
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004255 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
4256 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
4257 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004258
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004259
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004260The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
4261with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
4262combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
4263byte header containing information about target architecture,
4264operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
4265stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004266
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004267"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
4268print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004269
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004270In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
4271contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
4272checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004273
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004274 tools/mkimage -l image
4275 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004276
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004277The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
4278from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004279
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004280 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
4281 -n name -d data_file image
4282 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
4283 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
4284 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4285 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
4286 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
4287 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
4288 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
4289 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004290
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00004291Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
4292address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
4293kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004294
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004295- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
4296- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004297
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004298So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004299
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004300 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4301 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004302 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004303 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
4304 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4305 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4306 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4307 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4308 Load Address: 0x00000000
4309 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004310
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004311To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004312
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004313 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
4314 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4315 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4316 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4317 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4318 Load Address: 0x00000000
4319 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004320
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004321NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
4322speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
4323needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
4324need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004325
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004326 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004327 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4328 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004329 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004330 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
4331 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4332 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4333 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
4334 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
4335 Load Address: 0x00000000
4336 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004337
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004338
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004339Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
4340when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004341
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004342 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
4343 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
4344 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
4345 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4346 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
4347 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4348 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
4349 Load Address: 0x00000000
4350 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004351
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004352
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004353Installing a Linux Image:
4354-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004355
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004356To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
4357you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004358
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004359 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004360
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004361The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
4362image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
4363address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
4364specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
4365command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004366
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004367Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
4368TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004369
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004370 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004371
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004372 .......... done
4373 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004374
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004375 => loads 40100000
4376 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4377 ~>examples/image.srec
4378 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
4379 ...
4380 15989 15990 15991 15992
4381 [file transfer complete]
4382 [connected]
4383 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004384
4385
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004386You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004387this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004388corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004389
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004390 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004391
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004392 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4393 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4394 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4395 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4396 Load Address: 00000000
4397 Entry Point: 0000000c
4398 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004399
4400
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004401Boot Linux:
4402-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004403
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004404The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4405memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4406of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4407parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4408"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004409
4410
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004411 => printenv bootargs
4412 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004413
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004414 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004415
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004416 => printenv bootargs
4417 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004418
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004419 => bootm 40020000
4420 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4421 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4422 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4423 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4424 Load Address: 00000000
4425 Entry Point: 0000000c
4426 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4427 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4428 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4429 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4430 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4431 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4432 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4433 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004434
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004435If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004436the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4437format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004438
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004439 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004440
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004441 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4442 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4443 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4444 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4445 Load Address: 00000000
4446 Entry Point: 0000000c
4447 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004448
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004449 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4450 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4451 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4452 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4453 Load Address: 00000000
4454 Entry Point: 00000000
4455 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004456
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004457 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4458 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4459 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4460 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4461 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4462 Load Address: 00000000
4463 Entry Point: 0000000c
4464 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4465 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4466 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4467 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4468 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4469 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4470 Load Address: 00000000
4471 Entry Point: 00000000
4472 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4473 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4474 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4475 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4476 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4477 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4478 ...
4479 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4480 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004481
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004482 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004483
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004484Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4485-----------
4486
4487First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4488titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4489following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4490flat device tree:
4491
4492=> print oftaddr
4493oftaddr=0x300000
4494=> print oft
4495oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4496=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4497Speed: 1000, full duplex
4498Using TSEC0 device
4499TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4500Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4501Load address: 0x300000
4502Loading: #
4503done
4504Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4505=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4506Speed: 1000, full duplex
4507Using TSEC0 device
4508TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4509Filename 'uImage'.
4510Load address: 0x200000
4511Loading:############
4512done
4513Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4514=> print loadaddr
4515loadaddr=200000
4516=> print oftaddr
4517oftaddr=0x300000
4518=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4519## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004520 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4521 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4522 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004523 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004524 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004525 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4526 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4527Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4528Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4529Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4530[snip]
4531
4532
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004533More About U-Boot Image Types:
4534------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004535
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004536U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004537
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004538 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4539 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4540 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4541 the Standalone Program.
4542 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4543 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4544 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4545 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4546 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4547 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4548 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4549 being started.
4550 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4551 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4552 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4553 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4554 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4555 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004556
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004557 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4558 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4559 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4560 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4561 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4562 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004563
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004564 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4565 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4566 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004567
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004568 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4569 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4570 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4571 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004572
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004573Booting the Linux zImage:
4574-------------------------
4575
4576On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
4577using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
4578as the syntax of "bootm" command.
4579
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00004580Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_INITRD_RAW allows user to supply
4581kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
4582address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
4583format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
4584
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004585
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004586Standalone HOWTO:
4587=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004588
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004589One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4590run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4591U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004592
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004593Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004594
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004595"Hello World" Demo:
4596-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004597
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004598'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4599application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4600It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4601like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004602
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004603 => loads
4604 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4605 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
4606 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4607 [file transfer complete]
4608 [connected]
4609 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004610
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004611 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
4612 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4613 Hello World
4614 argc = 7
4615 argv[0] = "40004"
4616 argv[1] = "Hello"
4617 argv[2] = "World!"
4618 argv[3] = "This"
4619 argv[4] = "is"
4620 argv[5] = "a"
4621 argv[6] = "test."
4622 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
4623 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004624
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004625 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004626
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004627Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
4628handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
4629Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
4630The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
4631character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
4632controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004633
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004634 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
4635 b - enable interrupts and start timer
4636 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
4637 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004638
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004639 => loads
4640 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4641 ~>examples/timer.srec
4642 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4643 [file transfer complete]
4644 [connected]
4645 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004646
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004647 => go 40004
4648 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4649 TIMERS=0xfff00980
4650 Using timer 1
4651 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004652
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004653Hit 'b':
4654 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
4655 Enabling timer
4656Hit '?':
4657 [q, b, e, ?] ........
4658 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
4659Hit '?':
4660 [q, b, e, ?] .
4661 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
4662Hit '?':
4663 [q, b, e, ?] .
4664 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
4665Hit '?':
4666 [q, b, e, ?] .
4667 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
4668Hit 'e':
4669 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
4670Hit 'q':
4671 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004672
4673
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004674Minicom warning:
4675================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004676
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004677Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
4678"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
4679consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
4680Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
4681especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
4682use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command).
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004683
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004684Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
4685configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004686
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004687 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
4688 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
4689 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004690
4691
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004692NetBSD Notes:
4693=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004694
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004695Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
4696(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004697
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004698Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
4699NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
4700need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
4701Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
4702attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
4703missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004704
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004705 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
4706 # mkdir powerpc
4707 # ln -s powerpc machine
4708 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
4709 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004710
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004711Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
4712and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004713
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004714Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
4715stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
4716proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
4717tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00004718meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004719
4720
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004721Implementation Internals:
4722=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004723
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004724The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
4725implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
4726inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
4727hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004728
4729
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004730Initial Stack, Global Data:
4731---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004732
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004733The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
4734starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
4735system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
4736This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
4737is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
4738at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
4739options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
4740models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
4741MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
4742locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004743
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004744 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004745 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004746
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004747 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
4748 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
4749 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
4750 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004751
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004752 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
4753 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
4754 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
4755 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
4756 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004757 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004758 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
4759 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004760
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004761 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
4762 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004763 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004764 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
4765 board designers haven't used it for something that would
4766 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
4767 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004768
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004769 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004770 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
4771 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02004772 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004773 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
4774 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
4775 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
4776 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
4777 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004778
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004779 -Chris Hallinan
4780 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004781
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004782It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
4783code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004784
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004785* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
4786 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004787
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004788* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004789 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
4790 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004791
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004792* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
4793 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004794
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004795Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
4796normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
4797turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
4798simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
4799functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
4800functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
4801the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
4802place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
4803reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004804
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004805When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
4806relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
4807GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004808
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004809For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
4810 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004811 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004812 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
4813 R5-R10: parameter passing
4814 R13: small data area pointer
4815 R30: GOT pointer
4816 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004817
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01004818 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
4819 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
4820 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004821
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004822 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004823
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004824 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
4825 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
4826 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
4827 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
4828 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
4829 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004830
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00004831On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05004832 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
4833
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00004834 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05004835
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004836On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004837
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004838 R0: function argument word/integer result
4839 R1-R3: function argument word
4840 R9: GOT pointer
4841 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking if enabled)
4842 R11: argument (frame) pointer
4843 R12: temporary workspace
4844 R13: stack pointer
4845 R14: link register
4846 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004847
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004848 ==> U-Boot will use R8 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004849
Thomas Chou0df01fd2010-05-21 11:08:03 +08004850On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
4851 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
4852
4853 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
4854
4855 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
4856 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
4857
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004858On NDS32, the following registers are used:
4859
4860 R0-R1: argument/return
4861 R2-R5: argument
4862 R15: temporary register for assembler
4863 R16: trampoline register
4864 R28: frame pointer (FP)
4865 R29: global pointer (GP)
4866 R30: link register (LP)
4867 R31: stack pointer (SP)
4868 PC: program counter (PC)
4869
4870 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
4871
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02004872NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
4873or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004874
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004875Memory Management:
4876------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004877
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004878U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
4879MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004880
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004881The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
4882controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
4883memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
4884physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004885
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004886U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
4887TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
4888booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
4889to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004890memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004891configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
4892Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004893
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004894Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
4895of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004896
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004897So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
4898this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004899
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004900 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
4901 :
4902 0x0000 1FFF
4903 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
4904 :
4905 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004906
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004907 :
4908 :
4909 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
4910 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
4911 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
4912 :
4913 0x00FD FFFF
4914 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
4915 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
4916 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
4917 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004918
4919
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004920System Initialization:
4921----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004922
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004923In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004924(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004925configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
4926To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
4927To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
4928initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
4929which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
4930part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
4931the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004932
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004933Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
4934preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
4935(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
4936on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
4937programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
4938simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
4939banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004940
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004941When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
4942different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
4943bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
49440x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
4945contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004946
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004947Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
4948and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
4949Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
4950pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004951
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004952Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
4953until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
4954running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
4955new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004956
4957
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004958U-Boot Porting Guide:
4959----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004960
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004961[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
4962list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004963
4964
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004965int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004966{
4967 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004968
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004969 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
4970 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004971
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004972 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004973 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004974 return 0;
4975 }
4976
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004977 Download latest U-Boot source;
4978
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004979 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004980
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004981 if (clueless)
4982 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004983
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004984 while (learning) {
4985 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004986 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
4987 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004988 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004989 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004990 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004991
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004992 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
4993 Buy a BDI3000;
4994 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004995 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004996
4997 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
4998 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
4999 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
5000 } else {
5001 Create your own board support subdirectory;
5002 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005003 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005004 Edit new board/<myboard> files
5005 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005006
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005007 while (!accepted) {
5008 while (!running) {
5009 do {
5010 Add / modify source code;
5011 } until (compiles);
5012 Debug;
5013 if (clueless)
5014 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
5015 }
5016 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
5017 if (reasonable critiques)
5018 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
5019 else
5020 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005021 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005022
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005023 return 0;
5024}
5025
5026void no_more_time (int sig)
5027{
5028 hire_a_guru();
5029}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005030
5031
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005032Coding Standards:
5033-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005034
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005035All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005036coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005037"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005038
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005039Source files originating from a different project (for example the
5040MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
5041reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
5042sources.
5043
5044Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
5045Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
5046in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005047
5048Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
5049- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005050- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005051- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005052- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005053- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
5054
5055Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
5056with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005057
5058
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005059Submitting Patches:
5060-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005061
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005062Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
5063establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
5064may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005065
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02005066Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005067
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005068Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
5069see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
5070
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005071When you send a patch, please include the following information with
5072it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005073
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005074* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
5075 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
5076 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005077
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005078* For new features: a description of the feature and your
5079 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005080
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005081* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
5082
5083* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
5084
5085* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add this
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005086 board to the MAINTAINERS file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005087
5088* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
5089 document these in the README file.
5090
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005091* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
5092 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005093 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005094 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
5095 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005096
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005097 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
5098 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
5099 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005100
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005101 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
5102 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
5103 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
5104 affected files).
5105
5106 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
5107 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005108
5109* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
5110 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
5111
5112* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
5113 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
5114
5115
5116Notes:
5117
5118* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
5119 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
5120 for any of the boards.
5121
5122* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
5123 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
5124 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
5125
5126* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
5127 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
5128 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
5129 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
5130 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
5131 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00005132
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005133* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
5134 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
5135 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
5136 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.